| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | // -*- Mode: C++ -*-
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | #ifndef MAINWINDOW_H
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #define MAINWINDOW_H
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-12-06 05:41:16 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #include <QMainWindow>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-26 21:35:29 +01:00
										 |  |  | #include <QByteArray>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-13 16:04:41 +01:00
										 |  |  | #include <QString>
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #include <QStringList>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-12-06 05:41:16 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QLabel>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-07 23:09:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QThread>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-12-06 05:41:16 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QProcess>
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #include <QProgressBar>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QTimer>
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #include <QDateTime>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-05 13:57:55 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QList>
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #include <QAudioDeviceInfo>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-10 15:29:55 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QScopedPointer>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-12-03 00:06:54 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QDir>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-02-15 00:48:38 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QProgressDialog>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-15 16:40:49 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QAbstractSocket>
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #include <QHostAddress>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 01:45:40 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QPointer>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-10 15:54:16 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QSet>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-02-21 02:13:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QVector>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-21 01:36:30 +01:00
										 |  |  | #include <QQueue>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-10 15:54:16 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include <QFuture>
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #include <QFutureWatcher>
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-05 13:57:55 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-27 01:14:12 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "MultiGeometryWidget.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-09-24 17:57:06 +01:00
										 |  |  | #include "NonInheritingProcess.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-07-02 12:45:05 -05:00
										 |  |  | #include "Audio/AudioDevice.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "commons.h"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "Radio.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-11-07 17:49:45 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "models/Modes.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #include "models/FrequencyList.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "Configuration.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-07-02 12:45:05 -05:00
										 |  |  | #include "WSPR/WSPRBandHopping.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-07-02 10:19:43 -05:00
										 |  |  | #include "Transceiver/Transceiver.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-01-02 22:30:12 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "DisplayManual.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-21 02:15:31 +01:00
										 |  |  | #include "Network/PSKReporter.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-07-31 11:29:42 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "logbook/logbook.h"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "astro.h"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-03 20:31:19 +00:00
										 |  |  | #include "MessageBox.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-07-02 10:19:43 -05:00
										 |  |  | #include "Network/NetworkAccessManager.hpp"
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-25 01:48:45 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  | #define NUM_JT4_SYMBOLS 206                //(72+31)*2, embedded sync
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #define NUM_JT65_SYMBOLS 126               //63 data + 63 sync
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #define NUM_JT9_SYMBOLS 85                 //69 data + 16 sync
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #define NUM_WSPR_SYMBOLS 162               //(50+31)*2, embedded sync
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-03 15:45:54 +00:00
										 |  |  | #define NUM_MSK144_SYMBOLS 144             //s8 + d48 + s8 + d80
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-10-25 13:58:18 -04:00
										 |  |  | #define NUM_Q65_SYMBOLS 85                 //63 data + 22 sync
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-06-19 20:38:03 +00:00
										 |  |  | #define NUM_FT8_SYMBOLS 79
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-04-02 11:39:28 -04:00
										 |  |  | #define NUM_FT4_SYMBOLS 105
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-23 18:51:05 +01:00
										 |  |  | #define NUM_FST4_SYMBOLS 160             //240/2 data + 5*8 sync
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-07 23:09:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | #define NUM_CW_SYMBOLS 250
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2021-03-03 11:50:34 -05:00
										 |  |  | #define MAX_NUM_SYMBOLS 250
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-07 23:09:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | #define TX_SAMPLE_RATE 48000
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-01-18 16:22:25 -05:00
										 |  |  | #define NRING 3456000
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-07 23:09:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2021-03-03 11:50:34 -05:00
										 |  |  | extern int volatile itone[MAX_NUM_SYMBOLS];   //Audio tones for all Tx symbols
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-06 21:58:11 +00:00
										 |  |  | extern int volatile icw[NUM_CW_SYMBOLS];	    //Dits for CW ID
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-07 23:09:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | //--------------------------------------------------------------- MainWindow
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | namespace Ui { | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   class MainWindow; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | } | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-06 18:28:59 +00:00
										 |  |  | class QProcessEnvironment; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-12-06 05:41:16 +00:00
										 |  |  | class QSharedMemory; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | class QSplashScreen; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-10 15:29:55 +00:00
										 |  |  | class QSettings; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  | class QLineEdit; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-02-13 08:53:02 +00:00
										 |  |  | class QFont; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-15 16:40:49 +00:00
										 |  |  | class QHostInfo; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 16:42:38 +00:00
										 |  |  | class EchoGraph; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  | class FastGraph; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-10 15:29:55 +00:00
										 |  |  | class WideGraph; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | class LogQSO; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  | class Transceiver; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  | class MessageAveraging; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-11-12 04:44:03 +00:00
										 |  |  | class FoxLogWindow; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | class CabrilloLogWindow; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-08-25 11:19:43 -04:00
										 |  |  | class ColorHighlighting; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-15 16:40:49 +00:00
										 |  |  | class MessageClient; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | class QTime; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 01:45:40 +00:00
										 |  |  | class WSPRBandHopping; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-08 16:05:01 +00:00
										 |  |  | class HelpTextWindow; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-09 14:30:23 +00:00
										 |  |  | class WSPRNet; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-07-13 11:00:55 +00:00
										 |  |  | class SoundOutput; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | class Modulator; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | class SoundInput; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | class Detector; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-12-24 11:41:05 +00:00
										 |  |  | class SampleDownloader; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-17 23:39:12 +00:00
										 |  |  | class MultiSettings; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-14 15:33:17 +00:00
										 |  |  | class EqualizationToolsDialog; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-08-30 02:27:57 +00:00
										 |  |  | class DecodedText; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-10 15:29:55 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-27 01:14:12 +00:00
										 |  |  | class MainWindow | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   : public MultiGeometryWidget<3, QMainWindow> | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | { | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_OBJECT; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | public: | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   using Frequency = Radio::Frequency; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   using FrequencyDelta = Radio::FrequencyDelta; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-28 23:22:17 +00:00
										 |  |  |   using Mode = Modes::Mode; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-20 21:59:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   explicit MainWindow(QDir const& temp_directory, bool multiple, MultiSettings *, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                       QSharedMemory *shdmem, unsigned downSampleFactor, | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-06 18:28:59 +00:00
										 |  |  |                       QSplashScreen *, QProcessEnvironment const&, | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-20 21:59:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |                       QWidget *parent = nullptr); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   ~MainWindow(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-12-06 05:41:16 +00:00
										 |  |  |   int decoderBusy () const {return m_decoderBusy;} | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | public slots: | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void showSoundInError(const QString& errorMsg); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-05 13:57:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void showSoundOutError(const QString& errorMsg); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void showStatusMessage(const QString& statusMsg); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-10 15:29:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void dataSink(qint64 frames); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void fastSink(qint64 frames); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void diskDat(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void freezeDecode(int n); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void guiUpdate(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-10-13 22:34:36 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void doubleClickOnCall (Qt::KeyboardModifiers); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void doubleClickOnCall2(Qt::KeyboardModifiers); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-13 17:20:21 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void doubleClickOnFoxQueue(Qt::KeyboardModifiers); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-11-20 20:39:41 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void readFromStdout(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void p1ReadFromStdout(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void setXIT(int n, Frequency base = 0u); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-07-08 13:17:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void setFreq4(int rxFreq, int txFreq); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void msgAvgDecode2(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void fastPick(int x0, int x1, int y); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-27 01:14:12 +00:00
										 |  |  | private: | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void change_layout (std::size_t) override; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-30 16:25:47 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void keyPressEvent (QKeyEvent *) override; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-01 11:36:59 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void closeEvent(QCloseEvent *) override; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void childEvent(QChildEvent *) override; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool eventFilter(QObject *, QEvent *) override; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | private slots: | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-09 19:34:54 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void initialize_fonts (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_tx1_editingFinished(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_tx2_editingFinished(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_tx3_editingFinished(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_tx4_editingFinished(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_tx5_currentTextChanged (QString const&); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_tx6_editingFinished(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionSettings_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_monitorButton_clicked (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionAbout_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_autoButton_clicked (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_stopTxButton_clicked(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_stopButton_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-08-06 13:52:14 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionRelease_Notes_triggered (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-12 16:29:16 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionFT8_DXpedition_Mode_User_Guide_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-17 10:46:20 -05:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionQSG_FST4_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionQSG_Q65_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2021-05-31 16:19:29 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionQSG_X250_M3_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-09-24 23:46:32 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionOnline_User_Guide_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionLocal_User_Guide_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionWide_Waterfall_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionOpen_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionOpen_next_in_directory_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionDecode_remaining_files_in_directory_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-07-02 16:13:21 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionDelete_all_wav_files_in_SaveDir_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-10-04 11:47:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionOpen_log_directory_triggered (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionNone_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionSave_all_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionKeyboard_shortcuts_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionSpecial_mouse_commands_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-27 12:39:50 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionSolve_FreqCal_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-10-02 18:27:08 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionCopyright_Notice_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-10-04 00:46:59 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionSWL_Mode_triggered (bool checked); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_DecodeButton_clicked (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void decode(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void decodeBusy(bool b); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_EraseButton_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-16 22:20:51 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void band_activity_cleared (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-16 20:27:33 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void rx_frequency_activity_cleared (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txFirstCheckBox_stateChanged(int arg1); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-12-30 15:45:31 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void set_dateTimeQSO(int m_ntx); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void set_ntx(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-12-30 15:45:31 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txrb1_toggled(bool status); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-26 01:38:57 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txrb1_doubleClicked (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-12-30 15:45:31 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txrb2_toggled(bool status); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_txrb3_toggled(bool status); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-07 13:13:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txrb4_toggled(bool status); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-26 01:39:04 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txrb4_doubleClicked (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-07 13:13:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txrb5_toggled(bool status); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-24 19:27:23 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txrb5_doubleClicked (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-07 13:13:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txrb6_toggled(bool status); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_txb1_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-26 01:38:57 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txb1_doubleClicked (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txb2_clicked(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_txb3_clicked(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_txb4_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-26 01:39:04 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txb4_doubleClicked (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txb5_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-24 19:27:23 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txb5_doubleClicked (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_txb6_clicked(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_lookupButton_clicked(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_addButton_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-10 22:20:30 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_dxCallEntry_textChanged (QString const&); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_dxGridEntry_textChanged (QString const&); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-11-07 13:47:09 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_dxCallEntry_returnPressed (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_genStdMsgsPushButton_clicked(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_logQSOButton_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionJT9_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-07-08 13:17:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionJT65_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionJT4_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-01-28 10:19:46 -05:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionFT4_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-06-17 13:48:45 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionFT8_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-23 18:51:05 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionFST4_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionFST4W_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-10-05 19:14:45 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_TxFreqSpinBox_valueChanged(int arg1); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-10-30 16:49:24 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionSave_decoded_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-01-06 13:53:06 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionQuickDecode_toggled (bool); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionMediumDecode_toggled (bool); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionDeepestDecode_toggled (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-11-23 16:05:50 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void bumpFqso(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-03-18 16:14:18 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionErase_ALL_TXT_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-11-12 04:44:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_reset_cabrillo_log_action_triggered (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-03-18 16:14:18 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionErase_wsjtx_log_adi_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-01-08 15:41:59 -05:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionErase_WSPR_hashtable_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-10-03 16:25:36 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionExport_Cabrillo_log_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-03-24 17:29:26 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void startTx2(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-26 19:01:46 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void startP1(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-03-24 17:29:26 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void stopTx(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void stopTx2(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-04-08 18:31:21 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_rptSpinBox_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-04-12 17:57:20 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void killFile(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_tuneButton_clicked (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-04-24 16:05:04 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_pbR2T_clicked(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_pbT2R_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-04 22:42:35 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void acceptQSO (QDateTime const&, QString const& call, QString const& grid | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-15 16:40:49 +00:00
										 |  |  |                   , Frequency dial_freq, QString const& mode | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                   , QString const& rpt_sent, QString const& rpt_received | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                   , QString const& tx_power, QString const& comments | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-04 22:42:35 +00:00
										 |  |  |                   , QString const& name, QDateTime const& QSO_date_on, QString const& operator_call | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-12-02 10:09:37 -05:00
										 |  |  |                   , QString const& my_call, QString const& my_grid | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                   , QString const& exchange_sent, QString const& exchange_rcvd | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-25 19:58:47 +02:00
										 |  |  |                   , QString const& propmode, QByteArray const& ADIF); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-28 23:22:17 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_bandComboBox_currentIndexChanged (int index); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-09-08 15:24:55 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void on_bandComboBox_editTextChanged (QString const& text); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_bandComboBox_activated (int index); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-05-04 00:12:27 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_readFreq_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-07-08 13:17:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_RxFreqSpinBox_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-10 15:29:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_outAttenuation_valueChanged (int); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void rigOpen (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void handle_transceiver_update (Transceiver::TransceiverState const&); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void handle_transceiver_failure (QString const& reason); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionAstronomical_data_toggled (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-01-27 21:28:54 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionShort_list_of_add_on_prefixes_and_suffixes_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void band_changed (Frequency); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void monitor (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2021-04-22 23:05:07 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void end_tuning (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-11 22:50:44 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void stop_tuning (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void stopTuneATU(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void auto_tx_mode(bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionMessage_averaging_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-11-12 04:44:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_contest_log_action_triggered (); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_fox_log_action_triggered (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-08-25 11:19:43 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionColors_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-01-06 13:53:06 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionInclude_averaging_toggled (bool); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionInclude_correlation_toggled (bool); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionEnable_AP_DXcall_toggled (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2021-01-15 14:12:52 -05:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionAuto_Clear_Avg_toggled (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void VHF_features_enabled(bool b); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_sbSubmode_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_cbShMsgs_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-01-06 19:01:29 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_cbSWL_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_cbTx6_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-01 19:05:52 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_cbMenus_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-16 18:16:02 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_cbCQonly_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-09 19:25:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_cbFirst_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-10 13:43:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_cbAutoSeq_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-15 16:40:49 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void networkError (QString const&); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_ClrAvgButton_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-20 15:43:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionWSPR_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_syncSpinBox_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-03 17:43:27 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void on_TxPowerComboBox_currentIndexChanged(int); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbTxPercent_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_cbUploadWSPR_Spots_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void WSPR_config(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-26 02:58:04 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void uploadWSPRSpots (bool direct_post = false, QString const& decode_text = QString {}); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void TxAgain(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-10-04 22:41:52 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void uploadResponse(QString const& response); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_WSPRfreqSpinBox_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-09-05 10:34:55 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbFST4W_RxFreq_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_sbFST4W_FTol_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_pbTxNext_clicked(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 16:42:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionEcho_Graph_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionEcho_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionFast_Graph_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void fast_decode_done(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-01-05 18:35:26 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionMeasure_reference_spectrum_triggered(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_actionErase_reference_spectrum_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-01-15 21:43:40 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionMeasure_phase_response_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-05-27 20:04:44 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbTR_valueChanged (int); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-23 18:51:05 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbTR_FST4W_valueChanged (int); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-05-27 20:04:44 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbFtol_valueChanged (int); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_cbFast9_clicked(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-11-27 01:34:43 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbCQTxFreq_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_cbCQTx_toggled(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-03 15:45:54 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionMSK144_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-10-25 13:58:18 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionQ65_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-01-03 21:37:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_actionFreqCal_triggered(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-08-06 13:52:14 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void splash_done (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Improved frequency calibration
Measure check  box added to FreqCal  mode, check to record  to fmt.all
with  current  calibration correction  disabled,  uncheck  to see  the
impact of the current calibration parameters.
The  fmt.all  file  is  now  optionally  renamed  to  fmt.bak  when  a
calibration solution  is accepted.  This allows  users to  preserve an
fmt.all file that they might have edited for best fit.
A calibration procedure might proceed thus:-
1) select FreqCal mode,
2) step through suggested  calibration test frequencies deleting those
that have no usable signal,
3) enable "Menu->Tools->Execute frequency calibration cycle" and check
that suitable signals are present,
4) select a suitable FTol and T/R period,
5) check  "Measure" and let the  cycle complete a few  times to gather
data,
6) uncheck "Measure" to complete the data capture, optionally tidy the
fmt.all file with your favourite editor,
7) push "Menu->Tools->Solve for  calibration parameters" and accept if
you like what you see,
8) sit back and admire your accurately frequency calibrated station.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@8167 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2017-10-13 22:34:21 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_measure_check_box_stateChanged (int); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-07 17:09:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbNlist_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-11-15 20:47:24 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbNslots_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_sbMax_dB_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-09-16 17:02:40 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void on_sbF_Low_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void on_sbF_High_valueChanged(int n); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void chk_FST4_freq_range(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-11-30 18:45:51 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_pbFoxReset_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-04 18:18:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_comboBoxHoundSort_activated (int index); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-25 00:57:45 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void not_GA_warning_message (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-10-30 16:06:01 -05:00
										 |  |  |   void checkMSK144ContestType(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-04-08 12:36:05 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void on_pbBestSP_clicked(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-03 14:17:13 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void on_RoundRobin_currentTextChanged(QString text); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-09-05 15:22:18 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void  setTxMsg(int n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-12-05 13:47:36 -06:00
										 |  |  |   bool stdCall(QString const& w); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-06-25 14:35:58 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void remote_configure (QString const& mode, quint32 frequency_tolerance, QString const& submode | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                          , bool fast_mode, quint32 tr_period, quint32 rx_df, QString const& dx_call | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                          , QString const& dx_grid, bool generate_messages); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-03 15:45:54 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-01-27 21:28:54 +00:00
										 |  |  | private: | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void initializeAudioOutputStream (QAudioDeviceInfo, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       unsigned channels, unsigned msBuffered) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void stopAudioOutputStream () const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void startAudioInputStream (QAudioDeviceInfo const&, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       int framesPerBuffer, AudioDevice * sink, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       unsigned downSampleFactor, AudioDevice::Channel) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-07 00:55:05 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void suspendAudioInputStream () const; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void resumeAudioInputStream () const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void startDetector (AudioDevice::Channel) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-17 01:27:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void FFTSize (unsigned) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void detectorClose () const; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void finished () const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-29 19:23:54 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void transmitFrequency (double) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-06 21:58:11 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void endTransmitMessage (bool quick = false) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void tune (bool = true) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-29 14:47:46 -04:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void sendMessage (QString mode, unsigned symbolsLength, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       double framesPerSymbol, double frequency, double toneSpacing, | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |       SoundOutput *, AudioDevice::Channel = AudioDevice::Mono, | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |       bool synchronize = true, bool fastMode = false, double dBSNR = 99., | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                              int TRperiod=60) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void outAttenuationChanged (qreal) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void toggleShorthand () const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-08-08 17:12:48 +01:00
										 |  |  |   Q_SIGNAL void reset_audio_input_stream (bool report_dropped_frames) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-07 23:09:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-03-23 18:24:27 +00:00
										 |  |  | private: | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-06-25 14:35:58 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void set_mode (QString const& mode); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void astroUpdate (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-09-28 19:08:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void writeAllTxt(QString message); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-01 05:11:57 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void auto_sequence (DecodedText const& message, unsigned start_tolerance, unsigned stop_tolerance); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-27 01:14:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void trim_view (bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-20 16:44:11 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void foxTest(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-08-24 13:18:49 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void setColorHighlighting(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-03-14 12:03:07 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void chkFT4(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-12 13:30:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool elide_tx1_not_allowed () const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-06 18:28:59 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QProcessEnvironment const& m_env; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-12-04 14:17:01 +00:00
										 |  |  |   NetworkAccessManager m_network_manager; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-05-07 19:32:52 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_valid; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-08-06 13:52:14 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QSplashScreen * m_splash; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-14 10:42:11 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_revision; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_multiple; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-17 23:39:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   MultiSettings * m_multi_settings; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-09-11 01:09:50 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QPushButton * m_configurations_button; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-10 15:29:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QSettings * m_settings; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-10 15:54:16 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<Ui::MainWindow> ui; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-08-10 15:29:55 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Configuration m_config; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-06-03 00:35:20 +01:00
										 |  |  |   LogBook m_logBook;            // must be after Configuration construction
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 01:45:40 +00:00
										 |  |  |   WSPRBandHopping m_WSPR_band_hopping; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-07-07 19:02:25 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_WSPR_tx_next; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-03 20:31:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   MessageBox m_rigErrorMessageBox; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-12-24 11:41:05 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<SampleDownloader> m_sampleDownloader; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-14 15:33:17 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<EqualizationToolsDialog> m_equalizationToolsDialog; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-03-05 18:20:40 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<WideGraph> m_wideGraph; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 16:42:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<EchoGraph> m_echoGraph; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<FastGraph> m_fastGraph; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
											  
											
												Added support for use of "Standard" locations for writable files.
         This allows  writable files  to be  located in  the "correct"
         location for  each platform rather  than in the  directory of
         the  executable  which, in  general,  is  not recommended  or
         allowed in some cases.
         A preprocessor macro  WSJT_STANDARD_FILE_LOCATIONS is used to
         switch be tween old and new functionality, currently it is on
         by default.  It  can be turned off by defining  it to a false
         value (0)  or more simply  with cmake-gui setting  the option
         with  the same  name.  JTAlert  can  only work  with the  old
         non-standard file  locations until  Laurie VK3AMA  chooses to
         support the new file locations.
         Even  if the  above is  not  enabled; the  QSettings file  is
         written to a  user specific location so it will  be shared by
         all instances  of the  program (i.e.  across  upgrades).  See
         below for multiple concurrent instance support changes.
Added a command line parser module for Fortran.
         Added 'lib/options.f90'  to facilitate more  complex argument
         passing to jt9 to cover explicit file locations.
Changed the way multiple concurrent instances are handled.
         This is  to allow the program  to be run multiple  times from
         the same installation directory.
         A new wsjtx command line  optional argument is available "-r"
         or  "--rig"   which  enables  multiple   concurrent  instance
         support.  The  parameter of the  new option is a  unique name
         signifying  a rig  or equivalent.   The name  is used  as the
         shared memory segment key and  in window titles.  The name is
         also used to  access unique settings files  and writable data
         files like ALL.TXT  and log files.  No attempt  has been made
         to share these files between concurrent instances.
         If  "-r" or  "--rig" is  used  without a  parameter it  still
         enables  multiple   concurrent  instance  support   for  that
         instance.  All instances must use  a unique parameter, one of
         which may be empty.
         The        rig       name        is       appended        the
         QCoreApplication::applicationName() for convenient usage like
         window titles.
Set non Qt locale to "C".
         This ensures that C library functions give consistent results
         whatever the  system locale is set  to.  QApplication follows
         the system locale as before.  Thus using QApplication and its
         descendants  like widgets  and QString  for all  user visible
         formating will give correct l10n and using C/C++ library will
         give consistent formatting across locales.
Added top level C++ exception handling to main.cpp.
         Because  the   new  transceiver  framework   uses  exceptions
         internally, the main function now handles any exceptions that
         aren't caught.
Retired devsetup, replaced with Configuration.
         Configuration  is  a  class  that encapsulates  most  of  the
         configuration  behavior.   Because  rig configuration  is  so
         closely coupled with rig operation, Configuration serves as a
         proxy  for   access  to  the  rig   control  functions.   See
         Configuration.hpp  for  more  details  of  the  Configuration
         interface.
Menu changes.
         Various checkable  menu actions moved  from main menu  to the
         Configuration  dialog.   The  whole settings  menu  has  been
         retired with  the single  "Settings..."  action moved  to the
         file  menu  for  consistency  on  Mac  where  it  appears  as
         "Preferences" in line with Mac guidelines.
New data models for data used by the application.
         ADIF amateur band parameters,  free text message macros, spot
         working   frequencies  and,   station  information   (station
         descriptions and transverter offsets per band) each implement
         the  QAbstractItemModel interface  allowing them  to be  used
         directly with  Qt view widgets  (Bands.hpp, FrequencyList.hpp
         and, StationList.hpp).  Configuration  manages maintenance of
         an instance of  all but the former of the  above models.  The
         ADIF band  model is  owned by  Configuration but  requires no
         user maintenance as it is immutable.
Band combo box gets more functionality.
         This  widget is  now an  editable QComboBox  with some  extra
         input capabilities.
         The popup list is still the list of spot working frequencies,
         now  showing the  actual  frequency decorated  with the  band
         name.  This  allows multiple  spot frequencies  on a  band if
         required.
         The  line edit  allows direct  frequency entry  in mega-Hertz
         with  a completer  built  in to  suggest  the available  spot
         working frequencies.   It also  allows band name  entry where
         the  first  available  spot working  frequency  is  selected.
         Recognized band names are those  that are defined by the ADIF
         specification and  can be found  in in the  implementation of
         the ADIF bands model (Bands.cpp).
         If an out of band frequency  is chosen, the line edit shows a
         warning red  background and the  text "OOB".  Out of  band is
         only defined  by the  ADIF band limits  which in  general are
         wider than any entities regulations.
Qt 5.2 now supports default audio i/p and o/p devices.
         These devices are placeholders  for whatever the user defines
         as the  default device.   Because of  this they  need special
         treatment as  the actual device  used is chosen at  open time
         behind the scenes.
Close-down behavior is simplified.
         The close-down  semantics were broken such  that some objects
         were not being shut down cleanly, this required amendments to
         facilitate correct close down of threads.
User font selection added to Configuration UI.
         Buttons to set the application font and the font for the band
         and  Rx frequency  activity widgets  have been  added to  the
         Configuration UI to replace the file based font size control.
Free text macros now selected directly.
         The free text line edit  widgets are now editable combo boxes
         that have  the current free  text macro definitions  as their
         popup  list.   The old  context  menu  to  do this  has  been
         retired.
Astronomical data window dynamically formatted and has font a chooser.
         This window is now autonomous,  has its own font chooser and,
         dynamically resizes to cover the contents.
Double click to Tx enabled now has its own widget in the status bar.
QDir used for portable path and file name handling throughout.
The  "Monitor", "Decode",  "Enable  Tx" and,  "Tune"  buttons are  now
checkable.
         Being checkable allows these  buttons control their own state
         and rendering.
Calls to PSK Reporter interface simplified.
         In   mainwindow.cpp  the   calls   to   this  interface   are
         rationalized to just 3 locations.
Manipulation of ALL.TXT simplified.
         Moved, where possible, to common functions.
Elevated frequency types to be Qt types.
         Frequency  and FrequencyDelta  defined as  Qt types  in their
         meta-type system  (Radio.hpp).  They  are integral  types for
         maximum accuracy.
Re-factored rig control calls in mainwindow.cpp.
         The new  Configuration proxy  access to rig  control required
         many changes  (mostly simplifications) to the  MainWindow rig
         control code.  Some  common code has been  gathered in member
         functions   like   qsy(),   monitor(),   band_changed()   and
         auto_tx_mode().
Rig control enhancements.
         The  rig control  for  clients interface  is  declared as  an
         abstract    interface   (See    Transceiver.hpp).    Concrete
         implementations of this interface are provided for the Hamlib
         rig  control library,  DX Lab  Suite Commander  via a  TCP/IP
         command channel, Ham  Radio Deluxe also via  a TCP/IP command
         channel and, OmniRig via its Windows COM server interface.
         Concrete Transceiver implementations are expected to be moved
         to a separate thread after construction since many operations
         are blocking  and not suitable  for running in a  GUI thread.
         To facilitate this all  instantiation of concrete Transceiver
         instances are handled by  Configuration using a factory class
         (TransceiverFactory)   for   configuration  parameter   based
         instantiation.
         Various   common  functionality   shared  by   different  rig
         interface implementations  are factored out into  helper base
         classes that  implement or delegate parts  of the Transceiver
         interface.  They  are TransceiverBase  which caches  state to
         minimize expensive rig commands, it also maps the Transceiver
         interface  into a  more  convenient  form for  implementation
         (template methods).  PollingTransceiver that provides a state
         polling   mechanism  that   only   reports  actual   changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver  that  provides  split  operation  by
         QSYing on PTT state changes.
         EmulateSplitTransceiver can  be used with  any implementation
         as  it follows  the GoF  Decorator pattern  and can  wrap any
         Transceiver implementation.
         OmniRigTransceiver is  derived directly  from TransceiverBase
         since  it doesn't  require  polling due  to its  asynchronous
         nature.  OmniRigTransceiver is only built on Windows as it is
         a COM server client.  To build  it you must first install the
         OmniRig     client     on     the     development     machine
         (http://www.dxatlas.com/omnirig/).
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver          derives          from
         PollingTransceiver since  it is a  synchronous communications
         channel.   No  third  party  library  is  required  for  this
         interface.
         HRDTransceiver also derives from PollingTransceiver.  The HRD
         interface  library has  been  reverse  engineered to  provide
         functionality with  all available versions of  HRD.  No third
         party libraries are required.
         HamlibTransceiver  likewise  derives from  PollingTransceiver
         since  the Hamlib  asynchronous interface  is non-functional.
         Although this  class will interface with  the release version
         of Hamlib (1.2.15.3);  for correct operation on  most rigs it
         needs to  run with the  latest master branch code  of Hamlib.
         During development many changes to Hamlib have been submitted
         and accepted,  hence this requirement.  Hamlib  source can be
         obtained from git://git.code.sf.net/p/hamlib/code  and at the
         time of writing he master branch was at SHA 6e4432.
         The Hamlib interface directly calls the "C" interface and the
         modified rigclass.{h,cpp} files have been retired.
         There is a rig type selection of "None" which may be used for
         non-CAT  rigs, this  is actually  a connection  to the  dummy
         Hamlib device.
         PollingTransvceiver   derives    from   TransceiverBase   and
         TransceiverBase derives from the Transceiver interface.
         Each interface implementation offers  some possibility of PTT
         control via  a different serial  port than the CAT  port.  We
         also support PTT  control directly via a  second serial port.
         This is done  by delegating to a dummy  Hamlib instance which
         is   only   used   for   PTT  control.    This   means   that
         DXLabSuiteCommanderTransceiver,       HRDTransceiver      and
         OmniRigTransceiver  always  wrap  a  dummy  HamlibTransceiver
         instance.  The  factory class TransceiverFactory  manages all
         these constructional complexities.
         Serial port  selection combo  boxes are  now editable  with a
         manually  entered value  being  saved to  the settings  file.
         This allows  a non-standard  port device  to be  used without
         having to edit the settings file manually.
         For TCP/IP  network CAT  interfaces; the network  address and
         port  may  be specified  allowing  the  target device  to  be
         located on a different machine  from the one running wsjtx if
         required.  The  default used when  the address field  is left
         blank is the correct one for normal usage on the local host.
         Selecting a polling  interval of zero is  no longer possible,
         this  is because  the rig  control capability  can no  longer
         support one way connection.  This  is in line with most other
         CAT control software.
         In the Configuration dialog there are options to select split
         mode  control  by  the  software  and  mode  control  by  the
         software.  For  the former  "None", "Rig"  and "Fake  it" are
         available,  for  the latter  "None",  "USB"  and, "Data"  are
         available.  Because  tone generation is implicitly  linked to
         split mode  operation; it is  no longer possible to  have the
         software in split  mode and the rig not or  vice versa.  This
         may mean some rigs cannot be used in split mode and therefore
         not in dual JT65+JT9 until  issues with CAT control with that
         rig are  resolved.  Single  mode with VOX  keying and  no CAT
         control are still possible so even the most basic transceiver
         setup is supported as before.
         Configuration now  supports a  frequency offset  suitable for
         transverter   operation.     The   station    details   model
         (StationList.hpp) includes  a column  to store an  offset for
         each band if required.
CMake build script improvements.
         The CMakeLists.txt from the  'lib' directory has been retired
         with its  contents merged into the  top level CMakeLists.txt.
         Install  target support  has been  greatly improved  with the
         Release build  configuration now building a  fully standalone
         installation  on Mac  and Windows.   The Debug  configuration
         still   builds   an   installation   that   has   environment
         dependencies for  external libraries, which is  desirable for
         testing and debugging.
         Package target  support is largely complete  for Mac, Windows
         and, Linux, it should be possible to build release installers
         directly from CMake/CPack.
         Cmake FindXXXX.cmake  modules have been added  to improve the
         location of fftw-3 and Hamlib packages.
         Version numbers are now stored in Versions.cmake and work in
         concert with automatic svn revision lookup during build.  The
         version string becomes 'rlocal'± if there are any uncommitted
         changes in the build source tree.
Moved resource like files to Qt resources.
      	 Because location of resource files  (when they cannot go into
      	 the  installation directory  because of  packaging rules)  is
      	 hard to standardize.  I have used the Qt  resource system for
      	 all ancillary data files. Some  like kvasd.dat are dumped out
      	 to the temp (working directory)  because they are accessed by
      	 an external program, others like the audio samples are copied
      	 out so  they appear in  the data directory under  the default
      	 save directory.
git-svn-id: svn+ssh://svn.code.sf.net/p/wsjt/wsjt/branches/wsjtx@3929 ab8295b8-cf94-4d9e-aec4-7959e3be5d79
											
										 
											2014-03-26 13:21:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<LogQSO> m_logDlg; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QScopedPointer<Astro> m_astroWidget; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-08 16:05:01 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<HelpTextWindow> m_shortcuts; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QScopedPointer<HelpTextWindow> m_prefixes; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QScopedPointer<HelpTextWindow> m_mouseCmnds; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<MessageAveraging> m_msgAvgWidget; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-11-07 17:49:45 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<FoxLogWindow> m_foxLogWindow; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-11-12 04:44:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<CabrilloLogWindow> m_contestLogWindow; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-08-25 11:19:43 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QScopedPointer<ColorHighlighting> m_colorHighlighting; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Transceiver::TransceiverState m_rigState; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   Frequency  m_lastDialFreq; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_lastBand; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-14 17:05:14 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_lastCallsign; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Frequency  m_dialFreqRxWSPR;  // best guess at WSPR QRG
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2013-03-18 13:24:50 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-07-13 11:00:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Detector * m_detector; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-17 01:27:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   unsigned m_FFTSize; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-07-13 11:00:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   SoundInput * m_soundInput; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   Modulator * m_modulator; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   SoundOutput * m_soundOutput; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-12-07 20:34:56 +00:00
										 |  |  |   int m_rx_audio_buffer_frames; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-12-03 01:49:21 +00:00
										 |  |  |   int m_tx_audio_buffer_frames; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-07-13 11:00:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QThread m_audioThread; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-10-19 00:56:41 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint64  m_msErase; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint64  m_secBandChanged; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint64  m_freqMoon; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-22 18:30:35 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint64  m_fullFoxCallTime; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-06 17:11:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Frequency m_freqNominal; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   Frequency m_freqTxNominal; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   Astro::Correction m_astroCorrection; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-06 18:28:59 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_reverse_Doppler; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   double  m_tRemaining; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-05-22 12:44:28 -04:00
										 |  |  |   double  m_TRperiod; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 19:46:12 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   float   m_DTtol; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   float   m_t0; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   float   m_t1; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   float   m_t0Pick; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   float   m_t1Pick; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-09-29 13:29:20 +00:00
										 |  |  |   float   m_fCPUmskrtd; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_waterfallAvg; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_ntx; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-05-12 20:46:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_gen_message_is_cq; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-26 01:39:04 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_send_RR73; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_timeout; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-10-19 00:56:41 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_XIT; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_setftx; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_ndepth; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_sec0; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_RxLog; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_nutc0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_ntr; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_tx; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_hsym; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_nsps; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_hsymStop; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_inGain; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_ncw; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_secID; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-08 20:45:45 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_idleMinutes; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_nSubMode; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_nclearave; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_minSync; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_dBm; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-12 17:29:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_nWSPRdecodes; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_k0; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_kdone; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_nPick; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-08-09 16:06:17 +00:00
										 |  |  |   FrequencyList_v2::const_iterator m_frequency_list_fcal_iter; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_nTx73; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-09-17 13:34:40 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_UTCdisk; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-19 18:09:27 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_wait; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-11-02 20:35:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_isort; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_max_dB; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-14 16:50:46 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_nDXped=0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-06 17:05:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_nSortedHounds=0; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_nHoundsCalling=0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-07 17:09:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_Nlist=12; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-11-15 20:47:24 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_Nslots=5; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-07 15:38:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_nFoxMsgTimes[5]={0,0,0,0,0}; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-05 20:13:16 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_tAutoOn; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-04-13 19:20:37 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_tFoxTx=0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-05-14 18:45:23 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_tFoxTx0=0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-04-13 19:20:37 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_maxStrikes=3;      //Max # of repeats: 3 strikes and you're out
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_maxFoxWait=3;      //Max wait time for expected Hound replies
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_foxCQtime=10;      //CQs at least every 5 minutes
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_tFoxTxSinceCQ=999; //Fox Tx cycles since most recent CQ
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-04-18 14:04:52 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_nFoxFreq;          //Audio freq at which Hound received a call from Fox
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   qint32  m_nSentFoxRrpt=0;    //Serial number for next R+rpt Hound will send to Fox
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-02-21 10:08:18 -05:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_kin0=0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-02-28 15:03:39 -05:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_earlyDecode=41; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-03-05 15:37:31 -05:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_earlyDecode2=47; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-03-12 15:11:20 -04:00
										 |  |  |   qint32  m_nDecodes=0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_btxok;		//True if OK to transmit
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_diskData; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_loopall; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_decoderBusy; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_txFirst; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_auto; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_restart; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_startAnother; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_saveDecoded; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_saveAll; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_widebandDecode; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_call3Modified; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_dataAvailable; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bDecoded; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_noSuffix; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_decodedText2; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_freeText; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-03-17 14:59:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_sentFirst73; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   int     m_currentMessageType; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_currentMessage; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   int     m_lastMessageType; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_lastMessageSent; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-05-11 11:30:02 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_tBlankLine; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-22 17:48:03 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bShMsgs; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-12-30 21:46:29 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bSWL; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-26 02:58:04 +01:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_uploadWSPRSpots; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_uploading; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_grid6; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_tuneup; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_bTxTime; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_rxDone; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-11 22:42:41 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bSimplex; // not using split even if it is available
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-06 18:02:39 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bEchoTxOK; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 19:46:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bTransmittedEcho; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-11 15:32:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bEchoTxed; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bFastMode; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_bFast9; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_bFastDecodeCalled; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool    m_bDoubleClickAfterCQnnn; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-08 15:23:32 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bRefSpec; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-12-24 20:05:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bClearRefSpec; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-01-15 21:43:40 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bTrain; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-04-11 20:53:54 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bUseRef; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-09-28 19:08:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bFastDone; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-17 16:51:14 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bAltV; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-31 14:24:02 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bNoMoreFiles; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-11-22 15:47:59 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bDoubleClicked; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-09 19:25:28 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bCallingCQ; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-24 19:27:23 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bAutoReply; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-20 19:11:04 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bCheckedContest; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-05 15:16:29 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bWarnedSplit=false; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-10-08 09:08:52 -04:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bTUmsg; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-04-08 12:36:05 -04:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bBestSPArmed=false; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-09-18 11:30:23 -04:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bOK_to_chk=false; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2021-02-06 13:01:28 -05:00
										 |  |  |   bool    m_bSentReport=false; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-25 19:21:25 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-24 19:27:23 +00:00
										 |  |  |   enum | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     { | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       CALLING, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       REPLYING, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       REPORT, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       ROGER_REPORT, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       ROGERS, | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |       SIGNOFF | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     } | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-07-27 09:30:00 -04:00
										 |  |  |     m_QSOProgress;        //State machine counter
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-08-02 14:35:55 -04:00
										 |  |  |   enum {CALL, GRID, DXCC, MULT}; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-05-01 00:40:51 +00:00
										 |  |  |   int			m_ihsym; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   int			m_nzap; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   int			m_npts8; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   float		m_px; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-03-06 15:52:09 +00:00
										 |  |  |   float   m_pxmax; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-05-01 00:40:51 +00:00
										 |  |  |   float		m_df3; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   int			m_iptt0; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool		m_btxok0; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   int			m_nsendingsh; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   double	m_onAirFreq0; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool		m_first_error; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   char    m_msg[100][80]; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   // labels in status bar
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-02 00:25:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QLabel tx_status_label; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-28 14:33:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QLabel config_label; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-02 00:25:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QLabel mode_label; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QLabel last_tx_label; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QLabel auto_tx_label; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QLabel band_hopping_label; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-03-12 15:07:56 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QLabel ndecodes_label; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-02 00:25:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QProgressBar progressBar; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-09 18:35:25 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QLabel watchdog_label; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-01-11 15:00:43 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QFuture<void> m_wav_future; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QFutureWatcher<void> m_wav_future_watcher; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-10 15:54:16 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QFutureWatcher<void> watcher3; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-09 23:39:41 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QFutureWatcher<QString> m_saveWAVWatcher; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-09-24 17:57:06 +01:00
										 |  |  |   NonInheritingProcess proc_jt9; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   NonInheritingProcess p1; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   NonInheritingProcess p3; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-27 13:08:28 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   WSPRNet *wsprNet; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-26 19:01:46 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QTimer m_guiTimer; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-10 15:54:16 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QTimer ptt1Timer;                 //StartTx delay
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QTimer ptt0Timer;                 //StopTx delay
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QTimer logQSOTimer; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QTimer killFileTimer; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QTimer tuneButtonTimer; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QTimer uploadTimer; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QTimer tuneATU_Timer; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QTimer TxAgainTimer; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-01 11:36:59 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QTimer minuteTimer; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-08-06 13:52:14 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QTimer splashTimer; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-26 19:01:46 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QTimer p1Timer; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_path; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_baseCall; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_hisCall; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_hisGrid; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_appDir; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-01-08 08:41:47 -06:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_cqStr; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_palette; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_dateTime; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_mode; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-24 17:01:51 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_fnameWE;            // save path without extension
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_rpt; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-10-04 14:50:02 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_nextRpt; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_rptSent; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_rptRcvd; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_qsoStart; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_qsoStop; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-13 16:04:41 +01:00
										 |  |  |   QStringList m_cmndP1; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_msgSent0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-01-22 17:06:57 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_calls; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-08-25 16:59:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_CQtype; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-11-29 19:43:27 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_opCall; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-06 17:05:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_houndCallers;        //Sorted list of Hound callers
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-27 21:06:57 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_fm0; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-21 15:48:56 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_fm1; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-07-31 15:42:51 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_xSent;               //Contest exchange sent
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_xRcvd;               //Contest exchange received
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-08-03 16:31:19 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_currentBand; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-10-04 14:50:02 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_nextCall; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QString m_nextGrid; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-01-03 12:15:48 -05:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_fileDateTime; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-03-07 14:36:58 -05:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_inQSOwith; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-04-08 12:36:05 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_BestCQpriority; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-10 15:54:16 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QSet<QString> m_pfx; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QSet<QString> m_sfx; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-04-11 20:32:17 +00:00
										 |  |  |   struct FoxQSO       //Everything we need to know about QSOs in progress (or recently logged).
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-21 20:55:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   { | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-04-13 19:20:37 +00:00
										 |  |  |     QString grid;       //Hound's declared locator
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     QString sent;       //Report sent to Hound
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     QString rcvd;       //Report received from Hound
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     qint32  ncall;      //Number of times report sent to Hound
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     qint32  nRR73;      //Number of times RR73 sent to Hound
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     qint32  tFoxRrpt;   //m_tFoxTx (Fox Tx cycle counter) when R+rpt was received from Hound
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     qint32  tFoxTxRR73; //m_tFoxTx when RR73 was sent to Hound
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-21 20:55:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   }; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-04-11 20:32:17 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QMap<QString,FoxQSO> m_foxQSO;       //Key = HoundCall, value = parameters for QSO in progress
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QMap<QString,QString> m_loggedByFox; //Key = HoundCall, value = logged band
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-13 17:20:21 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-02-20 10:43:30 -05:00
										 |  |  |   struct FixupQSO       //Info for fixing Fox's log from file "FoxQSO.txt"
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   { | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     QString grid;       //Hound's declared locator
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     QString sent;       //Report sent to Hound
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     QString rcvd;       //Report received from Hound
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |     QDateTime QSO_time; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   }; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QMap<QString,FixupQSO> m_fixupQSO;       //Key = HoundCall, value = info for QSO in progress
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-04-11 20:32:17 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QQueue<QString> m_houndQueue;        //Selected Hounds available for starting a QSO
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QQueue<QString> m_foxQSOinProgress;  //QSOs in progress: Fox has sent a report
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-22 15:31:09 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QQueue<qint64>  m_foxRateQueue; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-21 20:55:38 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-12-30 15:45:31 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QDateTime m_dateTimeQSOOn; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-03 21:59:59 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QDateTime m_dateTimeLastTX; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-03-12 11:09:49 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QDateTime m_dateTimeSentTx3; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QDateTime m_dateTimeRcvdRR73; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-04-16 13:21:45 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QDateTime m_dateTimeBestSP; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-09-21 14:35:16 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QDateTime m_dateTimeSeqStart;        //Nominal start time of Rx sequence about to be decoded
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QSharedMemory *mem_jt9; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-08-30 02:27:57 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString m_QSOText; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   unsigned m_downSampleFactor; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QThread::Priority m_audioThreadPriority; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool m_bandEdited; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool m_splitMode; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool m_monitoring; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-01 00:19:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_tx_when_ready; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_transmitting; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   bool m_tune; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-09 18:35:25 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_tx_watchdog;           // true when watchdog triggered
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-12-16 20:55:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_block_pwr_tooltip; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-25 20:24:09 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_PwrBandSetOK; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-11-02 18:45:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_bDisplayedOnce; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   Frequency m_lastMonitoredFrequency; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   double m_toneSpacing; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-02-15 00:48:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   int m_firstDecode; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QProgressDialog m_optimizingProgress; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-15 16:40:49 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QTimer m_heartbeat; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   MessageClient * m_messageClient; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-21 02:15:31 +01:00
										 |  |  |   PSKReporter m_psk_Reporter; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-01-02 22:30:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   DisplayManual m_manual; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-10-25 20:24:09 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QHash<QString, QVariant> m_pwrBandTxMemory; // Remembers power level by band
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   QHash<QString, QVariant> m_pwrBandTuneMemory; // Remembers power level by band for tuning
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-12-30 15:45:31 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QByteArray m_geometryNoControls; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-02-23 16:21:26 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QVector<double> m_phaseEqCoefficients; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-06-25 14:35:58 +01:00
										 |  |  |   bool m_block_udp_status_updates; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-02-21 02:13:13 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   //---------------------------------------------------- private functions
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void readSettings(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-09 19:34:54 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void set_application_font (QFont const&); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void setDecodedTextFont (QFont const&); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void writeSettings(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void createStatusBar(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void updateStatusBar(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-24 19:27:23 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void genStdMsgs(QString rpt, bool unconditional = false); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-11-27 01:34:43 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void genCQMsg(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-18 22:18:05 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void clearDX (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-07 13:32:18 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void lookup(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void ba2msg(QByteArray ba, char* message); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void msgtype(QString t, QLineEdit* tx); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void stub(); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void statusChanged(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-09-07 19:00:55 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void fixStop(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-11-12 13:30:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   bool shortList(QString callsign) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void transmit (double snr = 99.); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-03 20:31:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void rigFailure (QString const& reason); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void pskSetLocal (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-08-30 02:27:57 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void pskPost(DecodedText const& decodedtext); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-04-03 19:29:13 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void displayDialFrequency (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2014-09-24 17:25:19 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void transmitDisplay (bool); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-19 13:20:41 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void processMessage(DecodedText const& message, Qt::KeyboardModifiers = Qt::NoModifier); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-09-22 15:36:24 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void replyToCQ (QTime, qint32 snr, float delta_time, quint32 delta_frequency, QString const& mode, QString const& message_text, bool low_confidence, quint8 modifiers); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-02-04 22:42:35 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void locationChange(QString const& location); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-04-15 16:40:49 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void replayDecodes (); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void postDecode (bool is_new, QString const& message); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-15 23:03:11 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void postWSPRDecode (bool is_new, QStringList message_parts); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-05-28 23:22:17 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void enable_DXCC_entity (bool on); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void switch_mode (Mode); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-06 13:40:10 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void WSPR_scheduling (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-01-12 18:21:58 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void freqCalStep(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-11-27 01:34:43 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void setRig (Frequency = 0);  // zero frequency means no change
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-12 21:46:54 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void WSPR_history(Frequency dialFreq, int ndecodes); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-12 01:38:36 +01:00
										 |  |  |   QString beacon_start_time (int n = 0); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-07-01 12:01:47 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QString WSPR_message(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-11-18 01:28:12 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void fast_config(bool b); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-11-27 01:34:43 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void CQTxFreq(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-10-08 09:08:52 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void useNextCall(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-10-18 15:45:16 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void abortQSO(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-01-03 12:15:48 -05:00
										 |  |  |   void write_all(QString txRx, QString message); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-08-02 14:35:55 -04:00
										 |  |  |   bool isWorked(int itype, QString key, float fMHz=0, QString=""); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-08-02 11:05:36 -04:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-09 23:39:41 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString save_wave_file (QString const& name | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                           , short const * data | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2019-02-21 10:08:18 -05:00
										 |  |  |                           , int samples | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-06-09 23:39:41 +00:00
										 |  |  |                           , QString const& my_callsign | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                           , QString const& my_grid | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                           , QString const& mode | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                           , qint32 sub_mode | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                           , Frequency frequency | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                           , QString const& his_call | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                           , QString const& his_grid) const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-04-22 12:32:32 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void hound_reply (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-06 17:05:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   QString sortHoundCalls(QString t, int isort, int max_dB); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-13 17:20:21 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void rm_tb4(QString houndCall); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-01-11 15:00:43 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void read_wav_file (QString const& fname); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-05-07 19:32:52 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void decodeDone (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-06-26 21:35:29 +01:00
										 |  |  |   bool subProcessFailed (QProcess *, int exit_code, QProcess::ExitStatus); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-05-07 19:32:52 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void subProcessError (QProcess *, QProcess::ProcessError); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-05-24 10:08:35 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void statusUpdate () const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-09 18:35:25 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void update_watchdog_label (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-01 11:36:59 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void on_the_minute (); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void add_child_to_event_filter (QObject *); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void remove_child_from_event_filter (QObject *); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-02 00:25:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void setup_status_bar (bool vhf); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2016-07-09 18:35:25 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void tx_watchdog (bool triggered); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-18 21:50:00 +00:00
										 |  |  |   qint64  nWidgets(QString t); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void displayWidgets(qint64 n); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-03-10 16:26:42 -04:00
										 |  |  |   QChar current_submode () const; // returns QChar {0} if submode is not appropriate
 | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-07-08 18:44:42 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void write_transmit_entry (QString const& file_name); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-06 17:05:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void selectHound(QString t); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |   void houndCallers(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-22 14:51:22 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void foxRxSequencer(QString msg, QString houndCall, QString rptRcvd); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-06 17:05:48 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void foxTxSequencer(); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2017-12-21 20:55:38 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void foxGenWaveform(int i,QString fm); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2018-11-07 17:49:45 +00:00
										 |  |  |   void writeFoxQSO (QString const& msg); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2020-03-14 17:06:54 -04:00
										 |  |  |   void to_jt9(qint32 n, qint32 istart, qint32 idone); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2021-06-27 16:45:33 +01:00
										 |  |  |   bool is77BitMode () const; | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2021-08-18 13:38:49 +01:00
										 |  |  |   void cease_auto_Tx_after_QSO (); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | }; | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | extern int killbyname(const char* progName); | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | extern void getDev(int* numDevices,char hostAPI_DeviceName[][50], | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                    int minChan[], int maxChan[], | 
					
						
							|  |  |  |                    int minSpeed[], int maxSpeed[]); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2015-06-04 22:25:27 +00:00
										 |  |  | extern int next_tx_state(int pctx); | 
					
						
							| 
									
										
										
										
											2012-05-22 17:09:48 +00:00
										 |  |  | 
 | 
					
						
							|  |  |  | #endif // MAINWINDOW_H
 |